Top Banner
E-Rate & The Spring ISD Technology Plan
140

E-Rate

Jan 02, 2016

Download

Documents

Aaron Velazquez

E-Rate. & The Spring ISD Technology Plan. By: La’Kisha Williams Lamar University Educational Technology Leadership Graduate Studies EDLD 5362 “Information Systems Management”. Agenda. National Educational Technology Plan E-Rate Spring ISD Technology Plan - PowerPoint PPT Presentation
Welcome message from author
This document is posted to help you gain knowledge. Please leave a comment to let me know what you think about it! Share it to your friends and learn new things together.
Transcript
Page 1: E-Rate

E-Rateamp

The Spring ISD Technology Plan

>

By LarsquoKisha Williams

Lamar University Educational Technology Leadership

Graduate Studies

EDLD 5362 ldquoInformation Systems Managementrdquo

>

Agenda

National Educational Technology Plan E-Rate Spring ISD Technology Plan Improved Draft Technology Plan for Spring

ISD Conclusion Resources

>

National Educational Technology Plan

ldquoBy 2020 America will once again have the highest proportion of college graduates in the worldrdquomdashPresident Barack Obama Address to Congress February 24 2009

>

Netp Purpose

Transforming American Education

Through the Use of Technology

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp-2010

>

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 2: E-Rate

By LarsquoKisha Williams

Lamar University Educational Technology Leadership

Graduate Studies

EDLD 5362 ldquoInformation Systems Managementrdquo

>

Agenda

National Educational Technology Plan E-Rate Spring ISD Technology Plan Improved Draft Technology Plan for Spring

ISD Conclusion Resources

>

National Educational Technology Plan

ldquoBy 2020 America will once again have the highest proportion of college graduates in the worldrdquomdashPresident Barack Obama Address to Congress February 24 2009

>

Netp Purpose

Transforming American Education

Through the Use of Technology

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp-2010

>

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 3: E-Rate

Agenda

National Educational Technology Plan E-Rate Spring ISD Technology Plan Improved Draft Technology Plan for Spring

ISD Conclusion Resources

>

National Educational Technology Plan

ldquoBy 2020 America will once again have the highest proportion of college graduates in the worldrdquomdashPresident Barack Obama Address to Congress February 24 2009

>

Netp Purpose

Transforming American Education

Through the Use of Technology

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp-2010

>

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 4: E-Rate

National Educational Technology Plan

ldquoBy 2020 America will once again have the highest proportion of college graduates in the worldrdquomdashPresident Barack Obama Address to Congress February 24 2009

>

Netp Purpose

Transforming American Education

Through the Use of Technology

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp-2010

>

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 5: E-Rate

Netp Purpose

Transforming American Education

Through the Use of Technology

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp-2010

>

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 6: E-Rate

Targeted Areas for Goals

Learning Engage and Empower Assessment Measure What Matters Teacher Preparation and Connect Infrastructure Access and Enable Productivity Redesign and Transform

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 7: E-Rate

E-RATE Schools amp Libraries Program of the Universal

Service Fund

Discounts to schools for telecommunication amp Internet

To apply schools must have Technology Plan

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 8: E-Rate

Spring ISD Technology Plan

Objective

Every Class will provide frequent opportunities to use technology tools for

student learninghelliphellip

>

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 9: E-Rate

Strategy 1

Specific technology tools amp examples into curricula

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 10: E-Rate

Strategy 1 Resources- Curricula Instructional

Technology tools

Positions Involved- Exec Director for Curriculum Design

Assessments- Formative(May 2012)

Summative (May 2015)

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 11: E-Rate

Strategy 2

Expand student portal beyond pilot plan

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 12: E-Rate

Strategy 2 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative(Nov 2011)

Summative (May 2012)

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 13: E-Rate

Strategy 3

Implement Google Apps for Education for Students

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 14: E-Rate

Strategy 3 Resources- Current budget and Staffing

Positions Involved- Exec Dir of Tech Dir of Tech Services amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative Nov 2011Summative May 2012

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 15: E-Rate

Strategy 4

Desktop Virtualization to extend hardware life

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 16: E-Rate

Strategy 4 Resources- Current budget Tech Funds amp

Staffing

Positions Involved- Dir of Infrastructure Dir of Tech Services TelecommNetwork Specialist amp App Specialist

Assessments- Formative (Nov 2011) Summative (May 2012)

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 17: E-Rate

Professional Development Strategy

Provide professional learning aligned with Needs Assessments

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 18: E-Rate

Professional Development Strategy

Resource- Title IIA

Positions Involved- Executive Director for Systems Accountability

Formative Assessment- November 2011

Summative Assessment- August 2012

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 19: E-Rate

Where Are We Now

Laptops

Automated Gradebook

SpecializedSoftware

Training Classes

E-Mail Account

Class Computers

Ceiling Projector

Internet Access

Smart boards

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 20: E-Rate

Where We Need to BeDraft Technology Plan

(Patterned after CY-Fair ISDrsquos Technology Plan)

Technology Budget2012-2015

Teaching and Learning Budget 3744842 Educator Preparation and Development Budget

1023254 Leadership Administration and Support Budget

4400897 Infrastructure for technology Budget 18229689

>

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 21: E-Rate

Goal 1

Improve academic achievement by allowing students to participate in opportunities that allow collaboration communication critical thinking problem-solving creativity and innovation to solve real-world problems in an effort to achieve the Target Tech Level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 22: E-Rate

Objective 11

Increase the pattern of classroom use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by classrooms where teachers are seamlessly integrating technology in a student-centered environment

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 23: E-Rate

Strategies111

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide district support staff with 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012- July2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

AttendanceRecords Trainingdocuments

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 24: E-Rate

Strategies112

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and incorporate 21st Century LearningSkills such as the effective use of real-worldTools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessons in thecurriculummanagementSystem

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 25: E-Rate

Strategies113

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement 21st Century Learning Skills withincurrent content training and support structuresfor teachers

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Classes posted inAvatar Attendancerecords Coachingrecords

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 26: E-Rate

Strategies114

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Observe and provide feedback to teachers asthey implement 21st Century Learning Skillswithin content lessons

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Coaching recordswalk-though data

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 27: E-Rate

Strategies115

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Solicit and utilize feedback from students toenhance and improve content lessons andtechnology use in all classrooms

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Attendancerecords surveyresults

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 28: E-Rate

Objective 12

Increase the frequency of use of digital content to the Target Tech level by providing teachers with daily access and use of a variety of digital tools and resources

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 29: E-Rate

Strategies121

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Ensure that 21st Century Learning skillsincluding technology are integrated into lessonsthat are uploaded into the curriculummanagement system

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lessonsdeveloped

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 30: E-Rate

Strategies122

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitieson the use of interactive white boards onlineresources wireless laptops to support content

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Class offeringsattendance records

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 31: E-Rate

Strategies123

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Conduct professional development opportunitiesfor teachers on how to utilize digital tools to createstudent-generated 21st Century Learningprojects

August2012 -May 2013August2013-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Campus TechnologyTeams CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 32: E-Rate

Strategies124

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize the Internet and digital tools available tostudents to solve real-world problems

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 33: E-Rate

Objective 13

Increase content area connections to the Advanced Tech level as evidenced by teachers using technology to support the development of 21st Century Learning Skills and collaboration while incorporating technology in their subject area TEKS

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 34: E-Rate

Strategies131

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Model the use of collaborative tools (ie Adobe Connect Google Docs Web 20 tools)when providing professional development toincrease the use of the tools in the classroom

July 2012- August2015

All campus anddistrict-levelprofessionaldevelopment providers

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 35: E-Rate

Strategies132

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide weekly opportunities for students to useinteractive white boards online resourceslaptops and other digital tools to support 21stCentury

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministratorsCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 36: E-Rate

Strategies133

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning opportunities on theelementary middle and high school campusesto allow students to collaborate with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Classroom teachersInstructional Technology

Database reportswalk-through datalesson planscoaching reports

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 37: E-Rate

Strategies134

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide equal access for concurrent creditopportunities on all high school campusesthrough the utilization of distance learningequipment

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment CampusAdministrationInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Master schedulesindividual studentschedulescoaching reports

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 38: E-Rate

Strategies135

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide assistive technology devices ampsoftware for students for students with specialneeds as recommended by the AdmissionReview amp Dismissal(ARD)Committee

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Admission Review ampDismissal Committee(ARD) SpecialEducation DepartmentDesktop SupportServices

ARD recordsdelivery tickets

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 39: E-Rate

Strategies136

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize web-based programs to support academic achievement andadd to campuses as needed

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technologyand Desktop SupportServices Departments

Walk-through datapurchase ordersprogram reportsdata reviewsessions

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 40: E-Rate

Strategies137

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide instructional materials to persons withvisual impairments or other persons with printdisabilities

August2012 -May 2013August20123-May 2014August2014 -May 2015

Special EducationDepartment

Purchase ordersdelivery tickets

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 41: E-Rate

Objective 14

For grades K-8 increase the integration of Technology Applications (TA) TEKS as appropriate into content area and grade level instruction to the Advanced Tech level for grades 9-12 offer at least four Technology Applications high school courses

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 42: E-Rate

Strategies141

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote students engagement in learningactivities by providing teachers amp appraisers withcontent specific staff development on how digitaltools support and enhance the learningenvironment

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 43: E-Rate

Strategies142

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop and refine studentsrsquo 21st CenturyLearning skills by extending the depth ampcomplexity of lessons through the use of digitaltools

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartments

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 44: E-Rate

Strategies143

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement use of streaming video system toenhance the teaching of content TEKS

January2013 -May 2014

Technology NetworkServices InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Purchase orderscourse offeringsattendancerecordswalk-through data

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 45: E-Rate

Objective 15

Maintain student mastery of Technology Application (TA) TEKS (86 to 100) at the Target Tech level

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 46: E-Rate

Strategies151

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Work collaboratively with curriculum staff toensure that TA TEKS are addressed throughtopic specific lessons to ensure digital citizenshipamp Acceptable Use Policies are included incurriculum guides

July 2012- August2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 47: E-Rate

Strategies152

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to develop lessons that integratecontent and TA TEKS

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through datacurriculummanagementsystem lessons

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 48: E-Rate

Strategies153

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Design a content-based e-portfolio which utilizestechnology skills and tools for grades 2 amp 5 todetermine student progress on TA TEKS

July 2012- August2013

Instructional TechnologyDepartmentElementary Curriculumand Instruction

Attendancerecords lessonplans evaluationtools

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 49: E-Rate

Strategies154

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training for content teachers regardingstandards and rubrics to ensure consistentmeasurement of student attainment of TA TEKS

February2013 -August2013

Elementary Curriculumand InstructionInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 50: E-Rate

Strategies155

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a content-based e-portfolio whichutilizes technology skills and tools at the end of2nd 5th and 8th grades to measure studentattainment of TA TEKS

August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Student projectportfolio teacherrecords

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 51: E-Rate

Objective 16

Increase online learning to by allowing students to access teacher-created online TEKS-based content resources and learning activities amp interactive communications that support learning objectives throughout the curriculum

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 52: E-Rate

Strategies161

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum department to designprofessional development opportunities focusedon teaching teachers to create web-basedTEKS-based lessons for students

July 2012- July2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional Technology

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 53: E-Rate

Strategies162

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfor teachers to create and use web-basedlessons digital portfolios and wikis in theclassroom

July 2012- August2015

Curriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendancerecords trainingmaterials

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 54: E-Rate

Strategies163

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide opportunities for students to participatein wikis blogs Moodle Project Shareetc toenhance collaboration amp creativity with otherstudents

August2012 -May 2013August2013 -May 2014August2014-May 2015

Classroom TeachersCampus AdministrationCurriculum Instructionand SchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartment

Lesson planswalk-through data

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 55: E-Rate

Strategies164

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online learning opportunities via aSISD virtual school

July2012-May 2015

Curriculum Instructionamp SchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsstudent attendancerecords masterschedules studentschedules

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 56: E-Rate

Goal 2

Provide school district staff with opportunities to learn how to appropriately integrate technology as a tool utilizing collaborative interactive and customized learning environments in an effort to achieve the Target Tech level in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 57: E-Rate

Objective 21

Increase the content of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing opportunities for teachers to participate in the development of strategies to create new learning environments that empower students to think critically to solve real-world problems and collaborate with experts across business industry and higher education

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 58: E-Rate

Strategies211

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Meet with Campus Leadership Teams todetermine professional development needs fortheir campuses based on the Teacher STaRChart information

November2012November2013November2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

StaR Chart dataCampusImprovement Plan

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 59: E-Rate

Strategies212

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize online training site for teachers tounderstand the framework of the STaR Chart

September -October 2012September -October 2013September -October 2014

InstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Training materialscreatedAttendance recordsTeacher transcripts

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 60: E-Rate

Strategies213

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide campus staff with 21st Century LearningSkills training to incorporate higher-order thinkingskills increase the level of student engagementfocus on solving real-world problems amp useappropriate digital tools

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-throughs

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 61: E-Rate

Strategies214

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide staff with training to utilize distance learning tools to connect to other students professionals amp experts such as NASASmithsonian amp Connect 2 Texas to allowstudents to think critically amp collaborate outsidethe classroom

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 62: E-Rate

Objective 22

Increase the models of professional development to the Target Tech level by providing on-going professional development utilizing multiple staff development models

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 63: E-Rate

Strategies221

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with curriculum coordinators todesign professional development opportunitiesthat focus on the transparent use of technologyamp the alignment to content TEKS

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 64: E-Rate

Strategies222

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for district ampcampus leaders to recognize effective use oftechnology aligned with amp supporting districtinitiatives such as Rigor Relevance ampRelationships Marzanorsquos Strategies amp Differentiated Instruction

July 2012 -August 2015

C amp I andSchoolAdminDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Course offeringsfor administratorsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 65: E-Rate

Strategies223

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development opportunitiesfocused on technology skills for College andCareer Readiness

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 66: E-Rate

Objective 23

Increase the capabilities of educators to demonstrate proficiency of the five State Board of Education (SBEC) Standards to achieve the Target Tech level

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 67: E-Rate

Strategies231

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and evaluate products that provideteacher SBEC proficiency training

July 2012 -August 2012

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Agenda itemsmeeting dates

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 68: E-Rate

Strategies232

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Administer Pre- and Post- tests to determineSBEC teacher proficiencies

September2012September2013 (newstaff only)September2014 (newstaff only)

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency Reports

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 69: E-Rate

Strategies233

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Evaluate teacher progress in acquiring SBECproficiencies

May 2013May 2014May 2015

InstructionalTechnologyDepartmentCurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Proficiency reports

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 70: E-Rate

Strategies234

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Promote and encourage educator participation inthe Master Technology Teacher program

July 2012 -June 2015

InstructionalTechnology

Certificates ofcompletion

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 71: E-Rate

Objective 24

Increase participation in technology professional development (19-29 hours) to achieve the Advanced Tech level

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 72: E-Rate

Strategies241

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

July 2012 -August 2012

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnology

Training materials

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 73: E-Rate

Strategies242

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide training to promote 21st CenturyLearning Skills which include higher-orderthinking collaborative and interactive classroomenvironments real-world problem-solving and useof digital tools

August 2012- August2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsattendance records

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 74: E-Rate

Strategies243

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Collaborate with district staff to develop ampprovide the critical technology professionaldevelopment course offerings needed to promote21st Century Learning Skills --critical thinkingcollaboration communication creativity

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 75: E-Rate

Objective 25

Increase the levels of understanding and patterns of use to the Target Tech level as evidenced by most teachers utilizing digital tools in and across content areas to promote 21st Century Learning Skills

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 76: E-Rate

Strategies251

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize distance learning tools district-wide tofacilitate professional development opportunities

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyServicesNetwork SupportServices

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 77: E-Rate

Strategies252

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for teachers tocreate interactive online learning environments

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcriptsLesson PlansWalk-through dataMega-Monitoring

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 78: E-Rate

Strategies253

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide professional development for campusleadership teams on ways to communicate to thecommunity how technology is being utilized ontheir campuses (school newsletters campuswebsite etc)

July 2012 -August 2012July 2013 -August 2013July 2014 -August 2014

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

School newslettersCampus websitesCourse offeringsAttendance records

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 79: E-Rate

Strategies254

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of Volunteers in PublicSchools (VIPS) trained in the use of technologyby expanding the number amp location of trainingopportunities

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartment

Course offeringsAttendance dataCampus volunteerdata

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 80: E-Rate

Objective 26

Increase the professional development for online learning to Target Tech by promoting participation in professional development on the customization of online courses or content for appropriate subject areas

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 81: E-Rate

Strategies261

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Offer blended online and professional learningnetwork opportunities to assist administrators infocusing classroom instruction on 21st CenturyLearning Skills

July 2012 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchoolAdministrationDepartment

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 82: E-Rate

Strategies262

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide online professional development todistrict and campus staff on the effective use ofSISD Curriculum Management System

July 2012 -July 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchoolAdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyInformation Services

Course offeringsTeacher transcripts

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 83: E-Rate

Strategies263

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Develop capacity for creating amp facilitatingonline courses

July 2013 -August 2015

CurriculumInstruction ampSchool AdministrationDepartmentInstructionalTechnologyDepartmentNetwork ServicesDepartment

Course offerings

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 84: E-Rate

Goal 3

Increase the level of administrative support and use of technology in all focus areas as represented in the STaR Chart

>

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 85: E-Rate

Objective 31

Increase the degree to which campus and district leadership promotes continuous innovation with technology leading to increase student achievement and operating effectiveness

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 86: E-Rate

Strategies311

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide face to face or virtualtraining to principals that focuseson creating a 21st CenturyLearning environment at thecampus level

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartmentCampus Administration

Course offerings anditems on variousagendas

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 87: E-Rate

Strategies312

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include a technology agenda itemat each curriculum councilmeeting

August 2012ndash May 2015

Curriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationInstructional Technology

Agenda items

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 88: E-Rate

Strategies313

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement the curriculummanagement system toenable teachers ampadministrators to coordinate the use of electronic student data amp research-based strategies to create lessons to promote student achievement

August 2012- May 2015

C ampI and School AdminDepartmentCampus AdminInformation ServicesInstructional TechnologyDepartments

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 89: E-Rate

Strategies314

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Update the student managementSystem from Zangle to eSchoolPlus

July 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

System is deployed ampOperational

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 90: E-Rate

Strategies315

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement applicant trackingsystem

March 2012- August2012

Human Resources DepartmentInformation ServicesDepartment

System is deployed ampoperational

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 91: E-Rate

Strategies316

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement telephony systems

July 2012 -June 2015

Network Support ServicesHELP Desk

Bid approved andimplemented

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 92: E-Rate

Objective 32

Increase the level of technology involvement in district and campus plans such that technology benchmarks based on SBEC standards are established annually leading to the Advanced Tech level

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 93: E-Rate

Strategies321

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review the district technologyplan annually to ensure adequateyearly progress

May 2013May 2014May 2015

District Technology Committee

Agendas Committeerecommendations

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 94: E-Rate

Strategies322

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review SBEC standards withcampus principals and districtleaders

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendas

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 95: E-Rate

Strategies323

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Establish appropriate goals forSBEC benchmarks annually

August 2012August 2013August 2014

District Support Team

Meeting agendaspublished goals

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 96: E-Rate

Strategies324

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Include technology strategies atall levels in Campus ImprovementPlans

September2012September2013September2014

Campus Administrative TeamsDistrict Support Team

Campus ImprovementTemplates

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 97: E-Rate

Objective 33

Increase instructional support for the use of technology by creating learning communities and teacher cadres which allow for the use of technology to maximize teaching and learning

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 98: E-Rate

Strategies331

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Utilize professional learningcommunities strategies toenhance the teaching andlearning practices at all levels ofthe organization

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team

Usage of commonvocabulary data digsand dashboards anddata team protocols

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 99: E-Rate

Objective 34

Increase the degree to which campuses and the district uses technology to collaborate with and communicate with stakeholders to the Target Tech level

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 100: E-Rate

Strategies341

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to utilize webpage program tocreate teacher webpages To provide communication With students and parents

July 2012 -May 2015

Campus AdminTeachersDistrict Support TeamCurriculum Instruction ampSchool AdminDepartmentInstructional TechnologyDepartmentCampus Technology Liaisons

published teacherwebpages

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 101: E-Rate

Strategies342

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to stream video contentfrom the district website tocommunicate with all districtstakeholders

August 2012- May 2015

Communications Department

District website

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 102: E-Rate

Strategies343

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Enhance the parent portal toprovide additional information viathe district website

August 2012ndash May 2013

Information Services

Additional content andlinks added to parentportal

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 103: E-Rate

Strategies344

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue and expand podcastingof district and campus news andinformation

August 2012- May 2015

CommunicationsDepartment Campuses DistrictSupport Team CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration Department

District website

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 104: E-Rate

Strategies345

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to use telephonesystems communicationsfacilities internet access andvoice-mail to provide service tostudents patrons andemployees

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamNetwork Services

Frequency of use

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 105: E-Rate

Strategies346

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue conducting technologyeducation training for districtvolunteers

August 2012- May 2013August 2013- May 2014August 2014- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyDepartment

District VolunteerCourse offerings ondistrict website

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 106: E-Rate

Objective 35

Continue to provide the budgetary support for campuses to realize all technology strategies outlined in Campus Improvement Plans as specified at the Target Tech level

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 107: E-Rate

Strategies351

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Allocate funds on a per studentbasis to provide for suppliesincluding software paper tonercartridges etc

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 108: E-Rate

Strategies352

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide necessary funding fortraining via substitutes stipendsor required professionaldevelopment

August 2012- May 2015

District Support Team FinanceDepartment

Budgets

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 109: E-Rate

Objective 36

Increase online learning to the level of Target Tech as defined by the STaR Chart

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 110: E-Rate

Strategies361

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to explore newtechnologies to deliver onlinelearning opportunities

August 2012- May 2015

District Support TeamInstructional Technology Team

Expenditures anddistrict goalsMeeting notes

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 111: E-Rate

Strategies362

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to train curriculum staffon using Moodle to create onlinelearning opportunities for bothteachers and students

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional TechnologyCurriculum Instruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Online Course Offerings

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 112: E-Rate

Strategies363

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Increase the number of onlinecourses offered to staff andstudents

August 2012ndash May 2015

CurriculumInstruction andSchool AdministrationDepartment

Student and staffcourse offerings

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 113: E-Rate

Objective 37

Increase the degree to which campus and district administrators utilize technology to improve productivity and effectiveness

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 114: E-Rate

Strategies371

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide or upgrade PDAsPrincipal Toolkits andor othertechnologies to districtcampusadministrators to maximizeproductivity

August 2012- May 2015

Desktop Support Services

Purchase ordersdelivery ticketsinstallation records

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 115: E-Rate

Strategies372

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a training program toincrease the proficiencies ofcampusdistrict administrators inthe use of technology

August 2012- May 2015

Instructional Technology HELPDesk Curriculum Instruction amp School AdminDepartment amp DistrictSupport Team

Course offeringsattendance records

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 116: E-Rate

Goal 4

Provide an infrastructure system that allows all users 247 access to all e-learning opportunities and provide technical assistance to support instructional and administrative needs to achieve the Advanced or Target Tech levels in the Texas STaR Chart

>

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 117: E-Rate

Objective 41

Maintain a student-to-computer ratio of 275 to 1 maintain the five-year replacement cycle and implement the Target Tech ratio of 1 to 1 when needed

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 118: E-Rate

Strategies411

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computersand software to accommodategrowth

July 2012 -August 2015

Desktop Support ServicesTechnology Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 119: E-Rate

Strategies412

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Purchase and install computerand software to replace older computers maintaining afive-year replacement cycle

July 2012 ndashAugust 2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase ordersSoftware requests

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 120: E-Rate

Strategies413

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Maintain the High School Laptopproject assigning laptops to high schoolstudents

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

All high school USHistory studentsreceive laptops

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 121: E-Rate

Objective 42

Maintain and increase as necessary the districts internet connectivity and speed at the Target Tech level

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 122: E-Rate

Strategies421

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Bid and provide internet serviceat 500 megabits per second amp burstable to one Gigabit

July 2012 - July2015

Network Services

Contract awardinstallation verified

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 123: E-Rate

Strategies422

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide network access at allnew campuses

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Services

New facilities online

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 124: E-Rate

Strategies423

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Research and apply foropportunities to participate in thestate-wide telecommunicationsnetwork

June 2013 Network Services

Correspondencemeeting notes

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 125: E-Rate

Objective 43

Provide additional classroom technology to enhance student instruction at the Advanced Tech level

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 126: E-Rate

Strategies431

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Add digital storage for studentsand staff as necessary

July 2012 -December 2012

Network Services

Bid award Additionalstorage for students

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 127: E-Rate

Strategies432

Timeline

Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Provide technology and relatedequipment for new schools

July 2012 - June2012

Instructional TechnologyDepartment NetworkServices TechnologySupport Services DesktopSupport Services

Installation at newschools

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 128: E-Rate

Objective 44

Maintain current technical support levels at Developing Tech

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 129: E-Rate

Strategies441

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Use current staffing ratios tosupport technologyinfrastructure

July 2012 - July2015

Technology Services

Adopted budgetpersonnel records

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 130: E-Rate

Strategies442

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement tools for managingtechnology services andinfrastructure

July 2012 - June2015

Network Support ServicesDesktop Support Services

Purchase OrdersDelivery Tickets

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 131: E-Rate

Strategies443

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Review and maintain annuallythe districts disaster recoveryplan to ensure uninterruptednetwork services

October 2012October 2013October 2014

Disaster Recovery Team

Agendas

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 132: E-Rate

Objective 45

Improve local and wide area network capability to Target Tech capacity

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 133: E-Rate

Strategies451

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Continue to connect all rooms toa robust network

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 134: E-Rate

Strategies452

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace network servers every 5years

July 2012 -August 2015

Network Support Services

Purchase orders

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 135: E-Rate

Strategies453

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Replace aging printers asnecessary

July 2012 - June2015

Technology Support Services

Pick-up and Deliverytickets purchaseorders

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 136: E-Rate

Objective 46

Maintain and increase distance learning capacity to that of Advanced Tech

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 137: E-Rate

Strategies461

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Pilot Adobe Connect andwebcams with students tocollaborate and communicatebetween campuses

August 2012 -May 2014

Instructional TechnologyDepartment CurriculumInstruction and SchoolAdministration DepartmentNetwork Services

Purchase ordersLesson Plans Videosamples ConnectFiles

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 138: E-Rate

Strategies462

Timeline Person(s) Responsible

Evidence

Implement a digital video contentdelivery system toreplaceaugment cable TVinfrastructure

August 2012 -May 2013

Network Services District TV Studio InstructionalTechnology CurriculumInstruction amp SchoolAdministration Department

Purchase orders

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 139: E-Rate

Conclusion

The Nept plans to transform schools through the use of technology

E-Rate wants to help fund districts that have solid technology plans

The Spring ISD has started their technology transformation but is in need of a more extensive plan similar to that of the draft included in the presentation

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources
Page 140: E-Rate

Resources

httpwwwedgovtechnologynetp=2010

httpwwwusacorgsl httpwww2edgovaboutofficeslistoi

inonpubliceratehtml wwwspringisdorg httpwwwcfisdnetdept2technology

Technology20Planpdf

  • E-Rate
  • Slide 2
  • Agenda
  • National Educational Technology Plan
  • Netp
  • Targeted Areas for Goals
  • E-RATE
  • Spring ISD Technology Plan
  • Strategy 1
  • Strategy 1 (2)
  • Strategy 2
  • Strategy 2 (2)
  • Strategy 3
  • Strategy 3 (2)
  • Strategy 4
  • Strategy 4 (2)
  • Professional Development Strategy
  • Professional Development Strategy (2)
  • Where Are We Now
  • Where We Need to Be Draft Technology Plan (Patterned after CY-F
  • Goal 1
  • Objective 11
  • Slide 23
  • Slide 24
  • Slide 25
  • Slide 26
  • Slide 27
  • Objective 12
  • Slide 29
  • Slide 30
  • Slide 31
  • Slide 32
  • Objective 13
  • Slide 34
  • Slide 35
  • Slide 36
  • Slide 37
  • Slide 38
  • Slide 39
  • Slide 40
  • Objective 14
  • Slide 42
  • Slide 43
  • Slide 44
  • Objective 15
  • Slide 46
  • Slide 47
  • Slide 48
  • Slide 49
  • Slide 50
  • Objective 16
  • Slide 52
  • Slide 53
  • Slide 54
  • Slide 55
  • Goal 2
  • Objective 21
  • Slide 58
  • Slide 59
  • Slide 60
  • Slide 61
  • Objective 22
  • Slide 63
  • Slide 64
  • Slide 65
  • Objective 23
  • Slide 67
  • Slide 68
  • Slide 69
  • Slide 70
  • Objective 24
  • Slide 72
  • Slide 73
  • Slide 74
  • Objective 25
  • Slide 76
  • Slide 77
  • Slide 78
  • Slide 79
  • Objective 26
  • Slide 81
  • Slide 82
  • Slide 83
  • Goal 3
  • Objective 31
  • Slide 86
  • Slide 87
  • Slide 88
  • Slide 89
  • Slide 90
  • Slide 91
  • Objective 32
  • Slide 93
  • Slide 94
  • Slide 95
  • Slide 96
  • Objective 33
  • Slide 98
  • Objective 34
  • Slide 100
  • Slide 101
  • Slide 102
  • Slide 103
  • Slide 104
  • Slide 105
  • Objective 35
  • Slide 107
  • Slide 108
  • Objective 36
  • Slide 110
  • Slide 111
  • Slide 112
  • Objective 37
  • Slide 114
  • Slide 115
  • Goal 4
  • Objective 41
  • Slide 118
  • Slide 119
  • Slide 120
  • Objective 42
  • Slide 122
  • Slide 123
  • Slide 124
  • Objective 43
  • Slide 126
  • Slide 127
  • Objective 44
  • Slide 129
  • Slide 130
  • Slide 131
  • Objective 45
  • Slide 133
  • Slide 134
  • Slide 135
  • Objective 46
  • Slide 137
  • Slide 138
  • Conclusion
  • Resources